blob: 572699302f5f5ec467bb627ddad3f0dc4e0b8c1a [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
62 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
63 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() &&
168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000381
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
478 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000479 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
480 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000482 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 << D->getIdentifier();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
487 }
488 }
489 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000491 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000493 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
494 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
495 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000496 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000497}
498
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000499/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
500/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
501/// actual member.
502///
503/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
504/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
505/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
506/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
507/// we found.
508///
509/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
510/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
511/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
512VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
513 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000514 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
515 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
516 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
517
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000518 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000519 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
520 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
521 do {
522 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000523 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000524 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000525 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000526 else {
527 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
528 break;
529 }
530 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000531 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533
534 return BaseObject;
535}
536
537Sema::OwningExprResult
538Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
539 FieldDecl *Field,
540 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
541 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
542 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000543 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000544 AnonFields);
545
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000546 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
547 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
548 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
549 // found via name lookup.
550 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000551 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000552 if (BaseObject) {
553 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
554 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000555 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000556 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000557 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000558 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 BaseQuals
560 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
562 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
563 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
564 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
565 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000566 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000567 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
568 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
569 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else {
573 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
574 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
575 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000576 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
577 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000579 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 = Context.getTagDeclType(
581 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
582 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000583 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
585 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
586 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000587 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000588 MD->getThisType(Context),
589 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
591 }
592 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000593 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
594 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 }
598
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000599 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
603
604 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
605 // anonymous struct/union.
606 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
609 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
610 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
611 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000612 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
613 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
614
615 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
616 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
617 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
618 ResultQuals.removeConst();
619
620 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
621 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
622
623 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
624 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
625
626 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
627 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
628 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
629
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000630 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000631 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000632 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000633 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
634 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 }
638
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000639 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000640}
641
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000642/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
643/// possibly a list of template arguments.
644///
645/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
646/// DecomposeTemplateName.
647///
648/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
649/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
650/// some way.
651static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
652 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
653 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
654 DeclarationName &Name,
655 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
656 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
657 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
658 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
659 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
660
661 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
662 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
663 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
664 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
665 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
666
667 TemplateName TName =
668 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
669
670 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
671 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
672 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
673 } else {
674 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
675 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
676 TemplateArgs = 0;
677 }
678}
679
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000680/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
681/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
682/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000683static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000684 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
685 return false;
686
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
688 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
689 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
690 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
691 if (!BaseRT) return false;
692
693 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000694 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000695 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
696 return false;
697 }
698
699 return true;
700}
701
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000702/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
703/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
704static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000705 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000707 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
708 if (!DC) return true;
709
710 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
711 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
712
713 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
714 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
715
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000716 return false;
717}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000718
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000719/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
720/// the prospective base classes.
721static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
722 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
723 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000724 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000725 return false;
726
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000727 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000728 if (!RD) return false;
729 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
730
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000731 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
732 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
733 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
734 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
735 if (!BaseRT) return false;
736
737 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000738 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
739 return false;
740 }
741
742 return true;
743}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000744
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000745enum IMAKind {
746 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
747 IMA_Static,
748
749 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
750 IMA_Mixed,
751
752 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
753 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
754 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
755
756 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
757 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
758 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
759
760 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
761 IMA_Instance,
762
763 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
764 IMA_Unresolved,
765
766 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
767 /// context is not an instance method.
768 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
769
770 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
771 /// non-class context.
772 IMA_AnonymousMember,
773
774 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
775 /// context is not an instance method.
776 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
777
778 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
779 /// class.
780 IMA_Error_Unrelated
781};
782
783/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
784/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
785/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
786/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
787/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
788/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
789static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
790 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000791 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000792
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000793 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000794 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000795 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
796 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000797
798 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
799 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
800
801 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
802 bool hasNonInstance = false;
803 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
804 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000805 NamedDecl *D = *I;
806 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000807 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
808
809 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
810 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
811 // that's a special case.
812 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
813 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
814 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
815 }
816 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
817 }
818 else
819 hasNonInstance = true;
820 }
821
822 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
823 // member reference.
824 if (Classes.empty())
825 return IMA_Static;
826
827 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
828 // an implicit member reference.
829 if (isStaticContext)
830 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
831
832 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
833 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
834 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
835 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000836 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000837 Classes))
838 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
839
840 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
841}
842
843/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
844static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
845 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
846 const LookupResult &R) {
847 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
848 SourceRange Range(Loc);
849 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
850
851 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
852 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
853 if (MD->isStatic()) {
854 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
855 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
856 << Range << R.getLookupName();
857 return;
858 }
859 }
860
861 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
862 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
863 return;
864 }
865
866 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000867}
868
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000869/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
870///
871/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000872bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +0000873 LookupResult &R, CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000874 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
875
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000876 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000877 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000878 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
879 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000880 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000882 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
883 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000884
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000885 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
886 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
887 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
888 // dependent name.
889 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
890 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000891 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
892 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
893
894 if (!R.empty()) {
895 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
896 R.suppressDiagnostics();
897
898 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
899 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
900 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
901 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
902
903 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
904 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
905 // Actually quite difficult!
906 if (isInstance)
907 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000908 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000909 else
910 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
911
912 // Do we really want to note all of these?
913 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
914 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
915
916 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
917 return false;
918 }
919 }
920 }
921
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000922 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000923 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000924 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000925 if (!R.empty()) {
926 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
927 if (SS.isEmpty())
928 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
929 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
930 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
931 else
932 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
933 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
934 << SS.getRange()
935 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
936 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
937 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
938 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
939 << ND->getDeclName();
940
941 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
942 return false;
943 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000944
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000945 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
946 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
947 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
948 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
949 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
950 // to recover well anyway.
951 if (SS.isEmpty())
952 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
953 else
954 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
955 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
956 << SS.getRange();
957
958 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
959 return true;
960 }
961 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000962 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000963 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000964 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000965 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000966 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000967 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000968 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
969 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000970 return true;
971 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000972 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000973 }
974
975 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
976 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
977 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
978 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
979 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
980 << SS.getRange();
981 return true;
982 }
983
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000984 // Give up, we can't recover.
985 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
986 return true;
987}
988
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000989Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000990 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000991 UnqualifiedId &Id,
992 bool HasTrailingLParen,
993 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
994 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
995 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
996
997 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +0000998 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +0000999
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001000 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001001
1002 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1003 DeclarationName Name;
1004 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1005 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001006 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1007 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001008
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001009 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001010
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001011 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1012 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001013 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1014 // (note: handled after lookup)
1015 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1016 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1017 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001018 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1019 // names a dependent type.
1020 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1021 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001022 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1023 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1024 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001025 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001026 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001027 TemplateArgs);
1028 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001029
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001030 // Perform the required lookup.
1031 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1032 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001033 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1034 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1035 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1036 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1037 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001038 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1039 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1040 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001041 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001042 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1043 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001044
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001045 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1046 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001047 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1048 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001049 if (E.isInvalid())
1050 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001051
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001052 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1053 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001054 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001055 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001056
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001057 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1058 return ExprError();
1059
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001060 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1061 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001062 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001063
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001064 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001065 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001066 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1067 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1068 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1069 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1070 }
1071
1072 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1073 // call, diagnose the problem.
1074 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001075 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001076 return ExprError();
1077
1078 assert(!R.empty() &&
1079 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001080
1081 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1082 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001083 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001084 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1085 R.clear();
1086 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1087 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1088 return move(E);
1089 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001090 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001091 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001092
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001093 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1094 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1095
1096 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001097 // Warn about constructs like:
1098 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1099 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001100 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1101 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001102 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001103 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001104 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001105 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001106 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001107 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1108 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001109 break;
1110 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001111
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001112 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1113 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001114 }
1115 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001116 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001117 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1118 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1119 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1120 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1121 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1122 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001124 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001125
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001126 QualType T = Func->getType();
1127 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001128 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001129 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1130 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001131 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001132 }
1133 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001134
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001135 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1136 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1137 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1138 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1139 // class member access expression.
1140 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1141 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001142 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001143 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001144 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1145 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001146 }
1147
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001148 if (TemplateArgs)
1149 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001150
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1152}
1153
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001154/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1155Sema::OwningExprResult
1156Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1157 LookupResult &R,
1158 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1159 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1160 case IMA_Instance:
1161 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1162
1163 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1164 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1165 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1166 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1167
1168 case IMA_Mixed:
1169 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1170 case IMA_Unresolved:
1171 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1172
1173 case IMA_Static:
1174 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1175 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1176 if (TemplateArgs)
1177 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1178 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1179
1180 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1181 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1182 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1183 return ExprError();
1184 }
1185
1186 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1187 return ExprError();
1188}
1189
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001190/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1191/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1192/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1193/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001194Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001195Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001196 DeclarationName Name,
1197 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1198 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001199 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001200 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1201
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001202 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001203 return ExprError();
1204
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001205 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1206 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1207
1208 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1209 return ExprError();
1210
1211 if (R.empty()) {
1212 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1213 return ExprError();
1214 }
1215
1216 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1217}
1218
1219/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1220/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1221/// additional lookup.
1222///
1223/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1224/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1225///
1226/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1227Sema::OwningExprResult
1228Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001229 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001230 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001231 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001232
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001233 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1234 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1235 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1236 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1237 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1238
1239 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1240 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1241 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001242 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001243
1244 bool LookForIvars;
1245 if (Lookup.empty())
1246 LookForIvars = true;
1247 else if (IsClassMethod)
1248 LookForIvars = false;
1249 else
1250 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1251 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001252 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001253 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001254 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001255 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1256 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1257 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1258 if (IsClassMethod)
1259 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1260 << IV->getDeclName());
1261
1262 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1263 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1264 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1265 return ExprError();
1266
1267 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1268 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1269 return ExprError();
1270
1271 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1272 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1273 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1274 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1275
1276 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1277 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1278 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1279 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001280 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001281 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1282 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1283 SelfName, false, false);
1284 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1285 return Owned(new (Context)
1286 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1287 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1288 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001289 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001290 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001291 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001292 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1293 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1294 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1295 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1296 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1297 }
1298 }
1299
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001300 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1301 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1302 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1303 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1304 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1305 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1306 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1307 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1308 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1309 }
1310 }
1311 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001312 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1313 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001314}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001315
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001316/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1317///
1318/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1319///
1320/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1321/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1322/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1323/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1324///
1325/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1326/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1327/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1328/// the class declaring the member.
1329///
1330/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1331/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1332/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001333bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001334Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1335 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001336 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001337 NamedDecl *Member) {
1338 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1339 if (!RD)
1340 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001341
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001342 QualType DestRecordType;
1343 QualType DestType;
1344 QualType FromRecordType;
1345 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1346 bool PointerConversions = false;
1347 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1348 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001349
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001350 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1351 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1352 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1353 PointerConversions = true;
1354 } else {
1355 DestType = DestRecordType;
1356 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001357 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001358 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1359 if (Method->isStatic())
1360 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001361
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001362 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1363 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001364
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001365 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1366 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1367 PointerConversions = true;
1368 } else {
1369 FromRecordType = FromType;
1370 DestType = DestRecordType;
1371 }
1372 } else {
1373 // No conversion necessary.
1374 return false;
1375 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001376
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001377 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1378 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001379
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001380 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1381 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1382 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001383
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001384 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1385 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1386
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001387 bool isLvalue
1388 = (From->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) && !PointerConversions;
1389
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001390 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001391 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001392 // class name.
1393 //
1394 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1395 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1396 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1397 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1398 //
1399 // class Base { public: int x; };
1400 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1401 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1402 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1403 //
1404 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1405 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1406 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1407 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001408 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001409 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1410 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1411 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1412
1413 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1414
1415 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1416 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1417 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1418 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001419 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001420 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001421 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001422 return true;
1423
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001424 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001425 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001426 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001427 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001428
1429 FromType = QType;
1430 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1431
1432 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1433 // we're done.
1434 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1435 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001436 }
1437 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001438
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001439 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001440
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001441 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1442 // down to the using declaration's type.
1443 //
1444 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1445 // class ever has member declarations.
1446 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1447 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1448 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1449 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1450
1451 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1452 // conversion is non-trivial.
1453 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1454 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001455 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001456 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001457 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001458 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001459
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001460 QualType UType = URecordType;
1461 if (PointerConversions)
1462 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001463 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001464 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001465 FromType = UType;
1466 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1467 }
1468
1469 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1470 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1471 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001472 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001473
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001474 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1475 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1476 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001477 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001478 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001479
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001480 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregoraae38d62010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001481 isLvalue, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001482 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001483}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001484
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001485/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001486static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001487 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001488 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1489 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001490 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1491 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1492 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001493 if (SS.isSet()) {
1494 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1495 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001496 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001497
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001498 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001499 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001500}
1501
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001502/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1503/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1504/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1505/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001506Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001507Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1508 LookupResult &R,
1509 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1510 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001511 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1512
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001513 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001514
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001515 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1516 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001517 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001518 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001519 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001520 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001521 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001522
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001523 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1524 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001525 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1526 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001527 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1528 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001529 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1530 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1531 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1532 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001533 }
1534
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001535 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1536 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1537 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001538 SS,
1539 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1540 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001541}
1542
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001543bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001544 const LookupResult &R,
1545 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001546 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1547 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1548 return false;
1549
1550 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001551 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001552 return false;
1553
1554 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001555 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001556 return false;
1557
1558 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1559 // normal lookup:
1560 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1561 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1562
1563 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1564 // -- a declaration of a class member
1565 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1566 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001567 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001568 return false;
1569
1570 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1571 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1572 // using-declaration
1573 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1574 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1575 // turn off ADL anyway).
1576 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1577 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1578 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1579 return false;
1580
1581 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1582 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1583 // template
1584 // And also for builtin functions.
1585 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1586 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1587
1588 // But also builtin functions.
1589 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1590 return false;
1591 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1592 return false;
1593 }
1594
1595 return true;
1596}
1597
1598
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001599/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1600/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1601/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1602/// will in fact be used.
1603static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1604 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1605 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1606 return true;
1607 }
1608
1609 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1610 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1611 return true;
1612 }
1613
1614 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1615 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1616 return true;
1617 }
1618
1619 return false;
1620}
1621
1622Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001623Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001624 LookupResult &R,
1625 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001626 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1627 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001628 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001629 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001630
1631 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1632 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1633 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001634 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1635 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001636 return ExprError();
1637
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001638 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1639 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1640 // we've picked a target.
1641 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1642
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001643 bool Dependent
1644 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001645 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001646 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001647 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1648 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001649 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001650 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1651 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001652
1653 return Owned(ULE);
1654}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001655
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001656
1657/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1658Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001659Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001660 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1661 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001662 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1663 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001664
1665 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1666 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001667
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001668 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1669 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1670 // a template argument list.
1671 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1672 << Template << SS.getRange();
1673 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1674 return ExprError();
1675 }
1676
1677 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1678 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1679 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001680 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001681 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001682 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001683 return ExprError();
1684 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001685
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001686 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1687 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1688 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1689 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001690 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001691 return ExprError();
1692
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001693 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1694 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001695 return ExprError();
1696
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001697 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1698 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1699 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1700 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001701 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001702 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1703 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1704 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001705 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001706 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001707 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1708 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1709 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1710 return ExprError();
1711 }
1712
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001713 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001714 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1715 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1716 return ExprError();
1717 }
1718
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001719 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001720 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001721 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001722 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001723 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001724 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1725 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001726 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001727
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001728 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001729 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1730 ExprTy, Loc, false,
1731 constAdded);
1732 QualType T = VD->getType();
1733 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !T->isDependentType() &&
1734 !T->isReferenceType()) {
1735 Expr *E = new (Context)
1736 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1737 SourceLocation());
1738
1739 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001740 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
1741 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001742 SourceLocation(),
1743 Owned(E));
1744 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001745 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001746 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanian8e739282010-06-08 17:52:11 +00001747 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001748 }
1749 }
1750 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001751 }
1752 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1753 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001754
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001755 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001756}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001757
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001758Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1759 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001760 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001761
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001762 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001763 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001764 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1765 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1766 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001767 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001768
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001769 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1770 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001771
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001772 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1773 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001774 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001775 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001776 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001777
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001778 QualType ResTy;
1779 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1780 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1781 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001782 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001783
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001784 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001785 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001786 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1787 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001788 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001789}
1790
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001791Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001792 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001793 bool Invalid = false;
1794 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1795 if (Invalid)
1796 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001797
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001798 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1799 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001800 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001801 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001802
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001803 QualType Ty;
1804 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1805 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1806 else if (Literal.isWide())
1807 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001808 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1809 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001810 else
1811 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001812
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001813 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1814 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001815 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001816}
1817
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001818Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1819 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001820 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1821 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001822 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001823 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001824 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001825 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001826 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001827
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001828 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001829 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1830 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001831 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001832
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001833 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001834 bool Invalid = false;
1835 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1836 if (Invalid)
1837 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001838
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001839 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001840 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001841 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001842 return ExprError();
1843
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001844 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001845
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001846 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001847 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001848 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001849 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001850 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001851 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001852 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001853 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001854
1855 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1856
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001857 using llvm::APFloat;
1858 APFloat Val(Format);
1859
1860 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001861
1862 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1863 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1864 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1865 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001866 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001867 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001868 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001869 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001870 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1871 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001872 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001873 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1874 }
1875
1876 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1877 << Ty
1878 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1879 }
1880
1881 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001882 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001883
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001884 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001885 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001886 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001887 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001888
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001889 // long long is a C99 feature.
1890 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001891 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001892 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1893
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001894 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001895 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001896
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001897 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1898 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1899 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001900 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1901 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001902 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001903 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001904 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1905 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001906
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001907 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1908 // be an unsigned int.
1909 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1910
1911 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001912 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001913 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1914 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001915 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001916
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001917 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1918 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1919 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1920 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001921 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001922 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001923 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001924 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001925 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001926 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001927
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001928 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001929 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001930 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001931
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001932 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1933 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1934 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1935 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001936 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001937 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001938 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001939 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001940 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001941 }
1942
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001943 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001944 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001945 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001946
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001947 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1948 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1949 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1950 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001951 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001952 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001953 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001954 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001955 }
1956 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001957
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001958 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1959 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001960 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001961 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001962 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001963 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001964 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001966 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1967 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001968 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001969 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001970 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001971
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001972 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1973 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001974 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001975 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976
1977 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001978}
1979
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001980Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
1981 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00001982 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001983 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001984 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001985}
1986
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00001987/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00001988/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00001989bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00001990 SourceLocation OpLoc,
1991 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
1992 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00001993 if (exprType->isDependentType())
1994 return false;
1995
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001996 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
1997 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
1998 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
1999 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2000 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2001 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2002
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002003 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002004 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002005 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002006 if (isSizeof)
2007 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2008 return false;
2009 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002010
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002011 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002012 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002013 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2014 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002015 return false;
2016 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002017
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002018 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002019 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2020 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002021 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002022
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002023 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002024 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002025 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002026 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2027 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002028 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002029
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002030 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2031 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2032 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2033 return true;
2034 }
2035
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002036 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002037}
2038
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002039bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2040 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2041 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002042
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002043 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002044 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2045 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002046
2047 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2048 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2049 return false;
2050
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002051 if (E->getBitField()) {
2052 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2053 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002054 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002055
2056 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2057 // bit-field.
2058 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002059 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002060 return false;
2061
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002062 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2063}
2064
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002065/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002066Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002067Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002068 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002069 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002070 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002071 return ExprError();
2072
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002073 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002074
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002075 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2076 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2077 return ExprError();
2078
2079 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002080 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002081 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2082 R.getEnd()));
2083}
2084
2085/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2086/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002087Action::OwningExprResult
2088Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002089 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2090 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2091 bool isInvalid = false;
2092 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2093 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2094 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2095 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002096 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002097 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2098 isInvalid = true;
2099 } else {
2100 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2101 }
2102
2103 if (isInvalid)
2104 return ExprError();
2105
2106 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2107 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2108 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2109 R.getEnd()));
2110}
2111
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002112/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2113/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2114/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002115Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002116Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2117 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002118 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002119 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002120
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002121 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002122 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2123 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2124 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002125 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002126
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002127 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2128 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2129 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2130
2131 if (Result.isInvalid())
2132 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2133
2134 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002135}
2136
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002137QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002138 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2139 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002140
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002141 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002142 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002143 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002144
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002145 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2146 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2147 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002148
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002149 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002150 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2151 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002152 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002153}
2154
2155
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002156
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002157Action::OwningExprResult
2158Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2159 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002160 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2161 switch (Kind) {
2162 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2163 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2164 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2165 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002166
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002167 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002168}
2169
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002170Action::OwningExprResult
2171Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2172 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002173 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2174 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2175
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002176 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2177 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002178
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002179 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002180 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2181 Base.release();
2182 Idx.release();
2183 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2184 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2185 }
2186
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002187 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002188 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002189 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2190 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2191 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002192 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002193 }
2194
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002195 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2196}
2197
2198
2199Action::OwningExprResult
2200Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2201 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2202 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2203 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2204
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002205 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002206 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2207 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2208 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002209
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002210 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002211
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002212 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002213 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002214 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002215 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002216 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2217 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002218 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2219 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2220 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2221 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002222 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002223 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2224 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002225 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002226 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002227 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002228 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2229 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002230 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002231 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002232 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002233 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2234 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2235 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002236 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002237 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002238 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2239 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2240 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2241 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002242 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002243 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002244 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002245
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002246 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2247 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002248 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2249 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002250 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002251 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2252 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2253 // force the promotion here.
2254 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2255 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002256 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2257 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002258 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2259
2260 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2261 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002262 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002263 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2264 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2265 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2266 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002267 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2268 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002269 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2270
2271 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2272 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002273 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002274 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002275 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2276 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002277 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002278 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002279 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2280 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002281 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2282 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002283
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002284 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002285 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2286 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002287 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2288
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002289 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002290 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2291 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002292 // incomplete types are not object types.
2293 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2294 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2295 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2296 return ExprError();
2297 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002298
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002299 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002300 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002301 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2302 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002303 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002304
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002305 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002306 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002307 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2308 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2309 return ExprError();
2310 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002311
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002312 Base.release();
2313 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002314 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002315 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002316}
2317
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002318QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002319CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002320 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002321 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002322 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2323 // see FIXME there.
2324 //
2325 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2326 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002327 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002328
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002329 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002330 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002331
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002332 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002333 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2334 // to be selected.
2335 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002336
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002337 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2338 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002339 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002340
2341 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2342 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002343 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002344 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2345 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002346 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002347 do
2348 compStr++;
2349 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002350 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002351 do
2352 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002353 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002354 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002355
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002356 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002357 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2358 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002359 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2360 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002361 return QualType();
2362 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002363
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002364 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2365 // operates on.
2366 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002367 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002368
2369 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002370 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002371
2372 while (*compStr) {
2373 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2374 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2375 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2376 return QualType();
2377 }
2378 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002379 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002380
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002381 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002382 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002383 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002384 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002385 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002386 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002387 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002388 if (HexSwizzle)
2389 CompSize--;
2390
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002391 if (CompSize == 1)
2392 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002393
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002394 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002395 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002396 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2397 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2398 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2399 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002400 }
2401 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002402}
2403
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002404static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002405 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002406 const Selector &Sel,
2407 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002408
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002409 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002410 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002411 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002412 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002413
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002414 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2415 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002416 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002417 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002418 return D;
2419 }
2420 return 0;
2421}
2422
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002423static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002424 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002425 const Selector &Sel,
2426 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002427 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2428 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002429 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002430 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002431 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002432 GDecl = PD;
2433 break;
2434 }
2435 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002436 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002437 GDecl = OMD;
2438 break;
2439 }
2440 }
2441 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002442 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002443 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2444 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002445 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002446 if (GDecl)
2447 return GDecl;
2448 }
2449 }
2450 return GDecl;
2451}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002452
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002453Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002454Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2455 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002456 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2457 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2458 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2459 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2460 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2461
2462 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2463 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2464 //
2465 // T* t;
2466 // t.f;
2467 //
2468 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2469 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2470 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2471 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002472 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002473 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2474 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002475 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002476 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002477 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002478 return ExprError();
2479 }
2480 }
2481
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002482 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002483 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002484
2485 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2486 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002487 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002488 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2489 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2490 SS.getRange(),
2491 FirstQualifierInScope,
2492 Name, NameLoc,
2493 TemplateArgs));
2494}
2495
2496/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2497/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2498/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2499static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2500 Expr *BaseExpr,
2501 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002502 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002503 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002504 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2505 // diagnostics.
2506 if (!BaseExpr)
2507 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002508
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002509 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2510 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002511}
2512
2513// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2514// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2515// type. The restriction here is:
2516//
2517// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2518// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2519// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2520//
2521// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2522// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2523// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2524// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2525bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2526 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002527 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002528 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002529 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2530 if (!BaseRT) {
2531 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2532 // dependent.
2533 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2534 return false;
2535 }
2536 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002537
2538 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002539 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2540 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002541 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002542 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002543
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002544 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2545 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2546 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2547 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2548
2549 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2550 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2551
2552 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2553 return false;
2554 }
2555
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002556 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002557 return true;
2558}
2559
2560static bool
2561LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2562 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002563 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2564 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002565 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2566 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002567 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002568 << BaseRange))
2569 return true;
2570
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002571 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2572 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2573 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2574
2575 bool MOUS;
2576 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2577 return false;
2578 }
2579
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002580 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2581 if (SS.isSet()) {
2582 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2583 // nested-name-specifier.
2584 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2585
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002586 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002587 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2588 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2589 return true;
2590 }
2591
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002592 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002593
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002594 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2595 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2596 << DC << SS.getRange();
2597 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002598 }
2599 }
2600
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002601 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2602 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002603
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002604 if (!R.empty())
2605 return false;
2606
2607 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2608 // for typos.
2609 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002610 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002611 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002612 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2613 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2614 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002615 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2616 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002617 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2618 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2619 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002620 return false;
2621 } else {
2622 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002623 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002624 }
2625
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002626 return false;
2627}
2628
2629Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002630Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002631 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002632 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002633 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2634 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2635 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2636 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2637
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002638 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2639 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002640 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002641 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2642 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2643 Name, NameLoc,
2644 TemplateArgs);
2645
2646 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002647
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002648 // Implicit member accesses.
2649 if (!Base) {
2650 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2651 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2652 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2653 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002654 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002655 return ExprError();
2656
2657 // Explicit member accesses.
2658 } else {
2659 OwningExprResult Result =
2660 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002661 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy(), TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002662
2663 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2664 Owned(Base);
2665 return ExprError();
2666 }
2667
2668 if (Result.get())
2669 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002670
2671 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2672 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002673 }
2674
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002675 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002676 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2677 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002678}
2679
2680Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002681Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2682 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2683 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002684 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002685 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002686 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2687 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002688 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002689 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002690 if (IsArrow) {
2691 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2692 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2693 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002694 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002695
2696 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2697 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2698 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2699 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2700
2701 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002702 return ExprError();
2703
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002704 if (R.empty()) {
2705 // Rederive where we looked up.
2706 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2707 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2708 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002709
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002710 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002711 << MemberName << DC
2712 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002713 return ExprError();
2714 }
2715
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002716 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2717 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2718 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2719 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2720 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2721 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2722 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2723 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2724 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2725 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002726 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002727 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002728 return ExprError();
2729
2730 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2731 // result.
2732 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002733 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002734 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002735 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002736 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002737
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002738 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2739 // pick a member.
2740 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2741
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002742 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2743 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2744 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002745 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2746 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002747 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2748 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002749 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002750
2751 return Owned(MemExpr);
2752 }
2753
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002754 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002755 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002756 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2757
2758 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2759
2760 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2761 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2762 // error cases.
2763 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2764 return ExprError();
2765
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002766 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2767 if (!BaseExpr) {
2768 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002769 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002770 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2771
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002772 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2773 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2774 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2775 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002776 }
2777
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002778 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2779 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2780 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2781 // explicitly qualified.
2782 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2783 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2784 }
2785
2786 // Check the use of this member.
2787 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2788 Owned(BaseExpr);
2789 return ExprError();
2790 }
2791
2792 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2793 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2794 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002795 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2796 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002797 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2798 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2799
2800 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2801 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2802 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2803 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2804 else {
2805 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2806 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2807 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2808
2809 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2810 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2811
2812 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2813 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2814 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2815 }
2816
2817 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002818 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002819 return ExprError();
2820 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002821 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002822 }
2823
2824 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2825 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2826 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002827 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002828 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2829 }
2830
2831 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2832 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2833 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002834 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002835 MemberFn->getType()));
2836 }
2837
2838 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2839 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2840 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002841 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002842 }
2843
2844 Owned(BaseExpr);
2845
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002846 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002847 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002848 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2849 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2850 else
2851 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2852 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002853
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002854 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2855 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002856 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002857 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002858}
2859
2860/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2861/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2862/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2863/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2864/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2865/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2866/// an ordinary member expression.
2867///
2868/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2869/// fixed for ObjC++.
2870Sema::OwningExprResult
2871Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002872 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002873 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002874 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002875 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002876
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002877 // Perform default conversions.
2878 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002879
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002880 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002881 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2882
2883 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2884 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002885
2886 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002887 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002888 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2889 // call, and continue on.
2890 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2891 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2892 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2893 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2894 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002895 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2896 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002897 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2898 ->isRecordType()))) {
2899 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2900 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2901 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002902 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002903
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002904 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002905 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002906 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00002907 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002908 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002909 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002910
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002911 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2912 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2913 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2914 }
2915 }
2916 }
2917
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002918 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2919 // use that.
2920 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002921 if (IsArrow) {
2922 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2923 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2924 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002925 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002926 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002927 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2928 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002929 }
2930 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002931 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2932 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2933 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2934 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002935 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002936 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002937 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002938
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002939 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2940 // use that.
2941 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2942 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2943 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2944 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2945 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2946 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2947 }
2948 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002949
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002950 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002951
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002952 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002953 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002954 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2955 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2956 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2957 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2958 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2959 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2960 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2961 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2962 // Check the use of this method.
2963 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2964 return ExprError();
2965 }
2966 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2967 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2968 Selector SetterSel =
2969 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2970 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2971 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2972 if (!Setter) {
2973 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2974 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002975 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002976 }
2977 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2978 if (!Setter)
2979 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002980
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002981 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2982 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002983
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002984 if (Getter || Setter) {
2985 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002986
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002987 if (Getter)
2988 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2989 else
2990 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2991 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
2992 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002993 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002994 PType,
2995 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
2996 }
2997 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
2998 << MemberName << BaseType);
2999 }
3000 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003001
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003002 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3003 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3004 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003005 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003006 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003007
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003008 if (IsArrow) {
3009 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003010 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003011 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3012 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003013 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3014 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3015 // struct MyRecord foo;
3016 // foo->bar
3017 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3018 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3019 // by now.
3020 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3021 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003022 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003023 IsArrow = false;
3024 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003025 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3026 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3027 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003028 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003029 } else {
3030 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3031 // type *foo;
3032 // foo.bar
3033 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3034 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3035 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3036 // the appropriate pointer type
3037 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3038 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3039 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3040 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3041 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003042 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003043 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3044 IsArrow = true;
3045 }
3046 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003047 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003048
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003049 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003050 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003051 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003052 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003053 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003054 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003055 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003056
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003057 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3058 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003059 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003060 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003061 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003062 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3063 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3064 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3065 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003066 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3067
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003068 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003069 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003070
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003071 if (!IV) {
3072 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3073 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3074 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003075 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003076 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003077 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003078 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3079 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003080 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3081 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003082 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003083 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003084 } else {
3085 Res.clear();
3086 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003087 }
3088 }
3089
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003090 if (IV) {
3091 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3092 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3093 // error cases.
3094 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3095 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003096
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003097 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3098 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3099 return ExprError();
3100 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3101 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3102 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3103 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3104 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3105 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3106 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3107 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3108 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3109 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3110 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3111 // AST for a function decl.
3112 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003113 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003114 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3115 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3116 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3117 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3118 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3119 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003120
3121 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3122 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003123 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003124 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003125 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003126 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3127 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003128 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003129 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003130 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003131
3132 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3133 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003134 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003135 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003136 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003137 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003138 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003139 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003140 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003141 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003142 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3143 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003144 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003145 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003146
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003147 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003148 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003149 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3150 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3151 // Check the use of this declaration
3152 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3153 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003154
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003155 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3156 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3157 }
3158 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3159 // Check the use of this method.
3160 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3161 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003162
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003163 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003164 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3165 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3166 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003167 }
3168 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003169
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003170 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003171 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003172 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003173
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003174 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3175 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003176 if (!IsArrow)
3177 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3178 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003179 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003180
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003181 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003182 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003183 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3184 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003185 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003186 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003187 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003188
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003189 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003190 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003191 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003192 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3193 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003194 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003195 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003196 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003197 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003198
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003199 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3200 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3201
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003202 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003203}
3204
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003205/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3206/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3207/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3208/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3209/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3210///
3211/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3212/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3213/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3214/// only be called
3215/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3216/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3217/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3218Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3219 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3220 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003221 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003222 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3223 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3224 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3225 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3226 return ExprError();
3227
3228 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3229
3230 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3231 DeclarationName Name;
3232 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3233 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3234 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3235 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3236
3237 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3238
3239 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3240 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3241 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3242
3243 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3244 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3245
3246 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3247 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003248 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3249 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003250 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003251 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3252 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3253 Name, NameLoc,
3254 TemplateArgs);
3255 } else {
3256 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003257 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3258 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003259
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003260 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3261 Owned(Base);
3262 return ExprError();
3263 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003264
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003265 if (Result.get()) {
3266 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3267 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3268 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3269 // call now.
3270 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3271 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
3272 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003273
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003274 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003275 }
3276
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003277 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003278 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3279 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003280 }
3281
3282 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003283}
3284
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003285Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3286 FunctionDecl *FD,
3287 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3288 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3289 Diag (CallLoc,
3290 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3291 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003292 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003293 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3294 } else {
3295 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3296 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3297
3298 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003299 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3300 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003301
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003302 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3303 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregor01afeef2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003304 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003305
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003306 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003307 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003308 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003309
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003310 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3311 InitializedEntity Entity
3312 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3313 InitializationKind Kind
3314 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3315 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3316 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3317
3318 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003319 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003320 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3321 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003322 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003323
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003324 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003325 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003326 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003327 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003328
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003329 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3330 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3331 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003332 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3333 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003334 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3335 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003336 }
3337
3338 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003339 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003340}
3341
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003342/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3343/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3344/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3345/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3346/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3347/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003348bool
3349Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003350 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003351 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003352 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3353 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003354 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003355 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3356 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003357 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003358
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003359 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3360 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3361 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3362 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3363 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003364 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003365 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003366 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003367 }
3368
3369 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3370 // them.
3371 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3372 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3373 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3374 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003375 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003376 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003377 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3378 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3379 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003380 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003381 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003382 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003383 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003384 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003385 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003386 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3387 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3388 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3389 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3390 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003391 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003392 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003393 if (Invalid)
3394 return true;
3395 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3396 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3397 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003398
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003399 return false;
3400}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003401
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003402bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3403 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3404 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3405 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3406 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3407 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003408 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003409 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3410 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3411 bool Invalid = false;
3412 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3413 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3414 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3415 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003416 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003417 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003418 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003419
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003420 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003421 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3422 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003423
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003424 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3425 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003426 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003427 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003428 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003429
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003430 // Pass the argument
3431 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3432 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3433 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003434
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003435
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003436 InitializedEntity Entity =
3437 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3438 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3439 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3440 SourceLocation(),
3441 Owned(Arg));
3442 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3443 return true;
3444
3445 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003446 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003447 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003448
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003449 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003450 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003451 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3452 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003453
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003454 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003455 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003456 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003457 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003458
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003459 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003460 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003461 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003462 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003463 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003464 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003465 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003466 }
3467 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003468 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003469}
3470
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003471/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003472/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3473/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003474Action::OwningExprResult
3475Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3476 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003477 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003478 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003479
3480 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3481 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003482
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003483 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003484 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003485 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003486
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003487 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003488 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3489 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3490 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3491 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3492 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003493 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003494 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3495 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003496
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003497 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3498 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003499
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003500 NumArgs = 0;
3501 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003502
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003503 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3504 RParenLoc));
3505 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003506
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003507 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003508 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003509 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3510 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003511 bool Dependent = false;
3512 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3513 Dependent = true;
3514 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3515 Dependent = true;
3516
3517 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003518 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003519 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3520
3521 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3522 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3523 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3524 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3525
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003526 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3527
3528 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3529 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3530 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3531 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3532 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3533 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3534 // method template.
3535 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003536 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3537 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003538 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003539
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003540 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3541 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003542 }
3543
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003544 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003545 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003546 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003547 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003548 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3549 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003550 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003551
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003552 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003553 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003554 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3555 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003556 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3557 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003558 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003559
3560 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3561 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003562 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3563 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003564
3565 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3566 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003567 TheCall.get(), 0))
3568 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003569
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003570 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003571 RParenLoc))
3572 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003573
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003574 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3575 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003576 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003577 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3578 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003579 }
3580 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003581 }
3582
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003583 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003584 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003585 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003586
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003587 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003588 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3589 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003590 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003591 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003592 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003593
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003594 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3595 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3596 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3597
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003598 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3599}
3600
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003601/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3602/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003603/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3604/// block-pointer type.
3605///
3606/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3607Sema::OwningExprResult
3608Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3609 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3610 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3611 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3612 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3613
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003614 // Promote the function operand.
3615 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3616
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003617 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3618 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003619 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3620 Args, NumArgs,
3621 Context.BoolTy,
3622 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003623
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003624 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3625 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3626 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3627 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003628 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003629 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003630 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3631 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003632 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003633 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003634 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003635 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003636 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003637 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003638 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3639 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3640
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003641 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003642 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003643 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3644 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003645 return ExprError();
3646
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003647 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003648 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003649
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003650 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003651 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003652 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003653 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003654 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003655 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003656
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003657 if (FDecl) {
3658 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3659 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3660 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisddcd1322009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003661 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003662 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003663 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003664 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3665 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3666 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3667 }
3668 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003669 }
3670
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003671 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003672 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3673 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3674 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003675 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3676 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003677 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3678 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003679 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003680 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003681 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003682 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003683
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003684 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3685 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003686 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3687 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003688
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003689 // Check for sentinels
3690 if (NDecl)
3691 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003692
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003693 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003694 if (FDecl) {
3695 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3696 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003697
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003698 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003699 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3700 } else if (NDecl) {
3701 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3702 return ExprError();
3703 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003704
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003705 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003706}
3707
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003708Action::OwningExprResult
3709Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3710 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003711 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003712 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003713 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003714
3715 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3716 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3717 if (!TInfo)
3718 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3719
3720 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3721}
3722
3723Action::OwningExprResult
3724Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3725 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3726 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003727 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003728
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003729 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003730 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003731 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3732 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003733 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3734 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003735 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003736 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003737 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003738 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003739
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003740 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003741 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003742 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003743 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003744 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003745 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3746 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3747 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3748 &literalType);
3749 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003750 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003751 InitExpr.release();
3752 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003753
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003754 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003755 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003756 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003757 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003758 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003759
3760 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003761
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003762 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003763 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003764}
3765
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003766Action::OwningExprResult
3767Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003768 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3769 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3770 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003771
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003772 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003773 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003774
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003775 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3776 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003777 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003778 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003779}
3780
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003781static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3782 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003783 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003784 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3785
3786 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3787 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003788 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3789 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003790 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003791 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3792 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3793 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003794
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003795 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3796 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3797 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3798 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3799 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3800 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3801 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3802 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003803
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003804 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3805 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3806 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3807 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3808 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3809 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003810
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003811 // FIXME: Assert here.
3812 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3813 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3814}
3815
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003816/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003817bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003818 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003819 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003820 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003821 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003822 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3823 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003824
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003825 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003826
3827 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3828 // type needs to be scalar.
3829 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3830 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003831 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3832 return false;
3833 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003834
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003835 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003836 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003837 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3838 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003839 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003840 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3841 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003842 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003843 return false;
3844 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003845
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003846 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003847 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003848 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003849 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003850 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003851 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003852 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003853 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003854 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3855 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3856 break;
3857 }
3858 }
3859 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3860 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3861 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003862 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003863 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003864 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003865
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003866 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3867 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3868 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3869 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003870
3871 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003872 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003873 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3874 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003875 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003876 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003877
3878 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003879 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003880
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003881 if (castType->isVectorType())
3882 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3883 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3884 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3885
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003886 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3887 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003888
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003889 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003890 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003891 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003892 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003893 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3894 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3895 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3896 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003897 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003898 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3899 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3900 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003901 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003902
3903 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003904 return false;
3905}
3906
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003907bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3908 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003909 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003910
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003911 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003912 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003913 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003914 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003915 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003916 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003917 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003918 } else
3919 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003920 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003921 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003922
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003923 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003924 return false;
3925}
3926
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003927bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003928 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003929 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003930
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003931 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003932
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003933 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3934 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003935 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3936 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3937 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3938 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003939 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003940 return false;
3941 }
3942
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003943 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003944 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3945 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003946 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3947 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3948 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3949 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003950
3951 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3952 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3953 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003954
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003955 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003956 return false;
3957}
3958
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003959Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003960Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003961 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3962 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3963 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003964
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003965 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3966 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3967 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003968 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003969
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003970 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003971 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003972 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003973 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3974 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003975
3976 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
3977}
3978
3979Action::OwningExprResult
3980Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
3981 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3982 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
3983
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003984 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003985 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003986 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003987 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003988 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00003989
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00003990 Op.release();
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003991 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003992 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00003993 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003994}
3995
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003996/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
3997/// of comma binary operators.
3998Action::OwningExprResult
3999Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4000 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4001 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4002 if (!E)
4003 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004004
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004005 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004006
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004007 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4008 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4009 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004010
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004011 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4012}
4013
4014Action::OwningExprResult
4015Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4016 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004017 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004018 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004019 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004020 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004021
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004022 // Check for an altivec literal,
4023 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004024 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4025 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4026 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4027 return ExprError();
4028 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004029 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4030 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4031 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4032 }
4033 else
4034 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4035 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004036
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004037 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4038 // then handle it as such.
4039 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004040 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4041 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4042 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4043
4044 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4045 // braces instead of the original commas.
4046 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004047 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4048 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004049 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4050 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004051 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004052 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004053 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004054 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4055 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004056 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004057 }
4058}
4059
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004060Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004061 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004062 MultiExprArg Val,
4063 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004064 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4065 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004066 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4067 Expr *expr;
4068 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4069 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4070 else
4071 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004072 return Owned(expr);
4073}
4074
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004075/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4076/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004077/// C99 6.5.15
4078QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4079 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004080 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4081 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4082 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4083
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004084 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4085 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4086 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4087 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4088 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4089 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004090
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004091 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004092 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4093 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4094 << CondTy;
4095 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004096 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004097
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004098 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004099 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4100 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004101
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004102 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4103 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004104 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4105 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4106 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004107 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004108
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004109 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4110 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004111 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4112 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004113 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004114 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004115 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004116 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004117 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004118 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004119
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004120 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004121 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004122 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4123 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4124 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4125 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4126 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4127 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4128 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004129 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4130 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004131 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004132 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004133 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4134 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004135 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004136 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004137 // promote the null to a pointer.
4138 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004139 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004140 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004141 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004142 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004143 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004144 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004145 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004146
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004147 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4148 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4149 QuestionLoc);
4150 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4151 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004152
4153
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004154 // Handle block pointer types.
4155 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4156 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4157 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4158 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004159 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4160 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004161 return destType;
4162 }
4163 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004164 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004165 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004166 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004167 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4168 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4169 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004170 return LHSTy;
4171 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004172 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004173 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4174 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004175
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004176 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4177 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004178 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004179 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004180 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4181 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4182 // to get a consistent AST.
4183 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004184 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4185 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004186 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004187 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004188 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004189 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4190 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004191 return LHSTy;
4192 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004193
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004194 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4195 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4196 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004197 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4198 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004199
4200 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4201 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4202 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004203 QualType destPointee
4204 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004205 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004206 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4207 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4208 // Promote to void*.
4209 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004210 return destType;
4211 }
4212 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004213 QualType destPointee
4214 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004215 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004216 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004217 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004218 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004219 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004220 return destType;
4221 }
4222
4223 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4224 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4225 return LHSTy;
4226 }
4227 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4228 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4229 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4230 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4231 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4232 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4233 // to get a consistent AST.
4234 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004235 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4236 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004237 return incompatTy;
4238 }
4239 // The pointer types are compatible.
4240 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4241 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4242 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4243 // type.
4244 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4245 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004246 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4247 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004248 return LHSTy;
4249 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004250
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004251 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4252 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4253 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4254 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004255 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004256 return RHSTy;
4257 }
4258 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4259 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4260 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004261 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004262 return LHSTy;
4263 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004264
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004265 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004266 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4267 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004268 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004269}
4270
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004271/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4272/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4273QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4274 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4275 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4276 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004277
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004278 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4279 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4280 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4281 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4282 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4283 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4284 return LHSTy;
4285 }
4286 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4287 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4288 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4289 return RHSTy;
4290 }
4291 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4292 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4293 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4294 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4295 return LHSTy;
4296 }
4297 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4298 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4299 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4300 return RHSTy;
4301 }
4302 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4303 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4304 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4305 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4306 return LHSTy;
4307 }
4308 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4309 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4310 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4311 return RHSTy;
4312 }
4313 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4314 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004315
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004316 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4317 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4318 return LHSTy;
4319 }
4320 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4321 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4322 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004323
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004324 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4325 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4326 // type. This allows
4327 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4328 // where B is a subclass of A.
4329 //
4330 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4331 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4332 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4333 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004334
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004335 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4336 // It could return the composite type.
4337 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4338 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4339 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4340 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4341 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4342 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4343 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4344 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4345 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4346 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4347 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4348 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4349 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4350 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004351 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004352 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4353 ;
4354 else {
4355 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4356 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4357 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4358 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4359 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4360 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4361 return incompatTy;
4362 }
4363 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4364 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4365 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4366 return compositeType;
4367 }
4368 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4369 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4370 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4371 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4372 QualType destPointee
4373 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4374 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4375 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4376 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4377 // Promote to void*.
4378 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4379 return destType;
4380 }
4381 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4382 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4383 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4384 QualType destPointee
4385 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4386 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4387 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4388 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4389 // Promote to void*.
4390 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4391 return destType;
4392 }
4393 return QualType();
4394}
4395
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004396/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004397/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004398Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4399 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4400 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4401 ExprArg RHS) {
4402 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4403 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004404
4405 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4406 // was the condition.
4407 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4408 if (isLHSNull)
4409 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004410
4411 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004412 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004413 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004414 return ExprError();
4415
4416 Cond.release();
4417 LHS.release();
4418 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004419 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004420 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004421 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004422}
4423
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004424// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004425// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004426// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4427// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4428// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004429Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004430Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004431 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004432
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004433 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4434 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4435 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4436 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4437 return Compatible;
4438 }
4439
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004440 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004441 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4442 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004443
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004444 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004445 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4446 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004447
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004448 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004449
4450 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4451 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4452 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004453 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004454 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004455 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004456
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004457 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4458 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004459 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004460 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004461 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004462 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004463
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004464 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004465 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4466 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004467 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004468
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004469 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004470 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004471 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004472
4473 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004474 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4475 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004476 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004477 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004478 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004479 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4480 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4481 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4482 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4483 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4484 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004485 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004486 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004487 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004488 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004489
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004490 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004491 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004492 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004493 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004494
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004495 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4496 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4497 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4498 // warning can be disabled.
4499 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4500 return ConvTy;
4501 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4502 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004503
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004504 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4505 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4506 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4507 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4508 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4509 do {
4510 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4511 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004512
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004513 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4514 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4515 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004516
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004517 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004518 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004519 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004520
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004521 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004522 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004523 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004524 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004525}
4526
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004527/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4528/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4529/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4530// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004531Sema::AssignConvertType
4532Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004533 QualType rhsType) {
4534 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004535
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004536 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004537 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4538 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004539
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004540 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4541 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4542 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004543
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004544 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004545
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004546 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004547 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004548 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004549
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004550 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4551 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4552 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4553 }
4554 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004555 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004556 return ConvTy;
4557}
4558
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004559/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4560/// for assignment compatibility.
4561Sema::AssignConvertType
4562Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004563 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4564 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004565 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4566 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004567 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004568 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004569 }
4570 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4571 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004572 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4573 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004574 return IncompatiblePointer;
4575 return Compatible;
4576 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004577 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004578 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004579 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004580 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4581 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4582 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4583 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4584 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4585 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004586
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004587 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4588 return Compatible;
4589 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4590 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004591 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004592}
4593
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004594/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4595/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004596/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4597///
4598/// int a, *pint;
4599/// short *pshort;
4600/// struct foo *pfoo;
4601///
4602/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4603/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4604/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4605/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4606///
4607/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004608/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004609///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004610Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004611Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004612 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4613 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004614 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4615 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004616
4617 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004618 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004619
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004620 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4621 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4622 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4623 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4624 return Compatible;
4625 }
4626
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004627 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4628 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4629 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4630 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4631 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4632 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4633 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004634 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004635 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004636 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004637 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004638 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004639 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4640 // to the same ExtVector type.
4641 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4642 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4643 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004644 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004645 return Compatible;
4646 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004647
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004648 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004649 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004650 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004651 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004652 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4653 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004654 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004655 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004656 }
4657 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004658 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004659
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004660 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4661 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004662 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004663
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004664 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004665 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004666 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004667
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004668 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004669 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004670
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004671 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004672 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004673 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4674 return Compatible;
4675 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004676 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004677 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4678 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004679 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004680
4681 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004682 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004683 return Compatible;
4684 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004685 return Incompatible;
4686 }
4687
4688 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4689 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004690 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004691
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004692 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004693 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004694 return Compatible;
4695
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004696 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4697 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004698
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004699 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004700 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004701 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004702 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004703 return Incompatible;
4704 }
4705
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004706 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4707 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4708 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004709
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004710 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004711 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004712 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4713 return Compatible;
4714 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004715 }
4716 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004717 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004718 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004719 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004720 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4721 return Compatible;
4722 }
4723 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4724 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4725 return Compatible;
4726 return Incompatible;
4727 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004728 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004729 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004730 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4731 return Compatible;
4732
4733 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004734 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004735
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004736 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004737 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004738
4739 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004740 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004741 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004742 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004743 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004744 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4745 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4746 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4747 return Compatible;
4748
4749 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4750 return PointerToInt;
4751
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004752 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004753 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004754 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4755 return Compatible;
4756 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004757 }
4758 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004759 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004760 return Compatible;
4761 return Incompatible;
4762 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004763
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004764 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004765 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004766 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004767 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004768 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004769}
4770
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004771/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4772/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004773static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004774 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4775 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4776 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004777 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004778 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004779 SourceLocation());
4780 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4781 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4782
4783 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4784 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004785 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004786 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004787 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004788}
4789
4790Sema::AssignConvertType
4791Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4792 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4793
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004794 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004795 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4796 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004797 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004798 return Incompatible;
4799
4800 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4801 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4802 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4803 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004804 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4805 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004806 it != itend; ++it) {
4807 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4808 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4809 // 1) void pointer
4810 // 2) null pointer constant
4811 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004812 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004813 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004814 InitField = *it;
4815 break;
4816 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004817
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004818 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004819 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004820 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004821 InitField = *it;
4822 break;
4823 }
4824 }
4825
4826 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4827 == Compatible) {
4828 InitField = *it;
4829 break;
4830 }
4831 }
4832
4833 if (!InitField)
4834 return Incompatible;
4835
4836 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4837 return Compatible;
4838}
4839
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004840Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004841Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004842 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4843 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4844 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4845 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4846 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004847 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004848 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004849 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004850 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004851 }
4852
4853 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4854 // structures.
4855 }
4856
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004857 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4858 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004859 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4860 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004861 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004862 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004863 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004864 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004865 return Compatible;
4866 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004867
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004868 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004869 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004870 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004871 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004872 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004873 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004874 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004875 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004876
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004877 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4878 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004879
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004880 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4881 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004882 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4883 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4884 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4885 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004886 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004887 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4888 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004889 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004890}
4891
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004892QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004893 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004894 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004895 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004896 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004897}
4898
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004899QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004900 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004901 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004902 QualType lhsType =
4903 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4904 QualType rhsType =
4905 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004906
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004907 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004908 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004909 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004910
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004911 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4912 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004913 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4914 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004915 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4916 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004917 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004918 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004919 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4920 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4921 return lhsType;
4922 }
4923
4924 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4925 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004926 }
4927 }
4928 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004929
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004930 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4931 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4932 bool swapped = false;
4933 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4934 swapped = true;
4935 std::swap(rex, lex);
4936 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4937 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004938
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004939 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004940 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004941 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004942 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004943 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004944 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004945 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4946 return lhsType;
4947 }
4948 }
4949 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4950 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4951 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004952 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004953 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4954 return lhsType;
4955 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004956 }
4957 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004958
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004959 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004960 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004961 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004962 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004963 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004964}
4965
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004966QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4967 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004968 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004969 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004970
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004971 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004972
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004973 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4974 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4975 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004976
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004977 // Check for division by zero.
4978 if (isDiv &&
4979 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004980 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004981 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004982
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004983 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00004984}
4985
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004986QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004987 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00004988 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4989 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4990 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4991 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4992 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004993
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004994 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004995
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004996 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4997 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004998
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004999 // Check for remainder by zero.
5000 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005001 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5002 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005003
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005004 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005005}
5006
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005007QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005008 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005009 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5010 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5011 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5012 return compType;
5013 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005014
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005015 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005016
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005017 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005018 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5019 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5020 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005021 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005022 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005023
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005024 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5025 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005026 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005027 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5028
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005029 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005030
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005031 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005032 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005033
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005034 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5035 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005036 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5037 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005038 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005039 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005040 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005041
5042 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5043 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5044 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005045 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005046 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5047 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5048 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5049 return QualType();
5050 }
5051
5052 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5053 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5054 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005055 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005056 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005057 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005058 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005059 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5060 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005061 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5062 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005063 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005064 return QualType();
5065 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005066 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005067 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005068 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5069 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5070 return QualType();
5071 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005072
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005073 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005074 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5075 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5076 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5077 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5078 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005079 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005080 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5081 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005082 return PExp->getType();
5083 }
5084 }
5085
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005086 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005087}
5088
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005089// C99 6.5.6
5090QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005091 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5092 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5093 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5094 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5095 return compType;
5096 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005097
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005098 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005099
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005100 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005101
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005102 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005103 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5104 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005105 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005106 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005107 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005108
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005109 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005110 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005111 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005112
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005113 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005114
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005115 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5116 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5117 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5118 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5119 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5120 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5121 return QualType();
5122 }
5123
5124 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5125 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5126 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5127 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5128 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005129 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005130 return QualType();
5131 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005132
5133 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5134 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5135 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005136 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005137 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005138 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005139 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005140 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005141
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005142 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005143 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005144 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5145 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5146 return QualType();
5147 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005148
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005149 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005150 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5151 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5152 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5153 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5154 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5155 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005156 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005157 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5158
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005159 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005160 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005161 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005162
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005163 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005164 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005165 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005166
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005167 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5168 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5169 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5170 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5171 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5172 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5173 return QualType();
5174 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005175
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005176 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5177 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5178 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5179 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005180 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005181 return QualType();
5182 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005183
5184 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5185 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5186 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5187 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5188 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005189 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5190 << rex->getSourceRange()
5191 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005192 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005193
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005194 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5195 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5196 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5197 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5198 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5199 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5200 return QualType();
5201 }
5202 } else {
5203 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5204 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5205 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5206 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5207 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5208 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5209 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5210 return QualType();
5211 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005212 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005213
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005214 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5215 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5216 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5217 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5218 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005219 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005220 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005221
5222 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005223 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5224 }
5225 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005226
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005227 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005228}
5229
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005230// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005231QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005232 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005233 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5234 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005235 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005236
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005237 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5238 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5239 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5240
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005241 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5242 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005243 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5244 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5245 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5246 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5247 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005248 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005249 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005250 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005251
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005252 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005253
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005254 // Sanity-check shift operands
5255 llvm::APSInt Right;
5256 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005257 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5258 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005259 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005260 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5261 else {
5262 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5263 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5264 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5265 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5266 }
5267 }
5268
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005269 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005270 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005271}
5272
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005273// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005274QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005275 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5276 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5277
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005278 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005279 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005280 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005281
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005282 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5283 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005284
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005285 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5286 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005287 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5288 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5289 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005290 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenekde9e9682009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005291 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005292 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5293 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5294 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005295 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenek9ffbe412009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005296 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005297 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl())) {
5298 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5299 << 0 // self-
5300 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::EQ
5301 || Opc == BinaryOperator::LE
5302 || Opc == BinaryOperator::GE));
5303 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5304 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5305 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5306 // what is it always going to eval to?
5307 char always_evals_to;
5308 switch(Opc) {
5309 case BinaryOperator::EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
5310 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5311 break;
5312 case BinaryOperator::NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
5313 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5314 break;
5315 default:
5316 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5317 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5318 break;
5319 }
5320 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5321 << 1 // array
5322 << always_evals_to);
5323 }
5324 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005325
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005326 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5327 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5328 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5329 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005330
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005331 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5332 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005333 Expr *literalString = 0;
5334 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005335 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005336 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005337 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005338 literalString = lex;
5339 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005340 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5341 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005342 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005343 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005344 literalString = rex;
5345 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5346 }
5347
5348 if (literalString) {
5349 std::string resultComparison;
5350 switch (Opc) {
5351 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5352 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5353 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5354 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5355 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5356 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5357 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5358 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005359
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005360 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5361 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5362 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005363 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005364 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005365 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005366
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005367 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5368 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5369 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5370 else {
5371 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5372 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5373 }
5374
5375 lType = lex->getType();
5376 rType = rex->getType();
5377
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005378 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005379 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005380
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005381 if (isRelational) {
5382 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005383 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005384 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005385 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005386 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005387 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005388
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005389 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005390 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005391 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005392
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005393 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005394 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005395 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005396 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005397
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005398 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5399 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005400 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005401 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005402 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005403 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005404 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005405
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005406 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005407 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5408 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005409 if (!isRelational &&
5410 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5411 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5412 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005413 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5414 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005415 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5416 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005417 Diag(Loc,
5418 isSFINAEContext()?
5419 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5420 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005421 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005422
5423 if (isSFINAEContext())
5424 return QualType();
5425
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005426 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5427 return ResultTy;
5428 }
5429 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005430 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5431 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5432 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5433 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5434 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5435 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005436 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005437 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005438 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005439 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005440 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005441 if (T.isNull()) {
5442 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5443 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5444 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005445 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005446 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005447 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005448 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005449 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005450 }
5451
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005452 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5453 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005454 return ResultTy;
5455 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005456 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5457 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5458 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5459 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5460 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5461 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5462 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5463 }
5464 } else if (!isRelational &&
5465 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5466 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5467 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5468 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5469 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5470 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5471 }
5472 } else {
5473 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005474 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005475 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005476 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005477 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005478 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005479 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005480 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005481
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005482 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005483 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005484 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005485 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005486 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5487 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005488 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005489 return ResultTy;
5490 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005491 if (LHSIsNull &&
5492 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5493 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005494 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005495 return ResultTy;
5496 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005497
5498 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005499 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005500 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5501 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005502 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5503 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5504 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5505 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5506 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5507 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5508 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5509 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005510 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005511 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005512 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005513 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005514 if (T.isNull()) {
5515 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005516 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005517 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005518 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005519 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005520 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005521 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005522 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005523 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005524
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005525 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5526 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005527 return ResultTy;
5528 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005529
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005530 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005531 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5532 return ResultTy;
5533 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005534
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005535 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005536 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005537 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5538 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005539
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005540 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005541 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005542 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005543 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005544 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005545 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005546 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005547 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005548 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005549 if (!isRelational
5550 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5551 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005552 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005553 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005554 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005555 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005556 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5557 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5558 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005559 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005560 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005561 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005562 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005563
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005564 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005565 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005566 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5567 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005568 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005569 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005570 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005571 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005572
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005573 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5574 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005575 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005576 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005577 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005578 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005579 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005580 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005581 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005582 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005583 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5584 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005585 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005586 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005587 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005588 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005589 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5590 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005591 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005592 bool isError = false;
5593 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5594 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5595 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005596 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005597 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005598 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005599 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5600 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5601 isError = true;
5602 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005603 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005604
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005605 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005606 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005607 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005608 if (isError)
5609 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005610 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005611
5612 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5613 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005614 else
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005615 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005616 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005617 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005618
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005619 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005620 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5621 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005622 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005623 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005624 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005625 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5626 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005627 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005628 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005629 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005630 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005631}
5632
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005633/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005634/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005635/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5636/// types.
5637QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005638 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005639 bool isRelational) {
5640 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5641 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005642 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005643 if (vType.isNull())
5644 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005645
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005646 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5647 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005648
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005649 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5650 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5651 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005652 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005653 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5654 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5655 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005656 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5657 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5658 << 0 // self-
5659 << 2 // "a constant"
5660 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005661 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005662
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005663 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005664 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5665 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005666 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005667 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005668
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005669 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5670 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5671 // elements for floating point vectors.
5672 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5673 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005674
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005675 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005676 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005677 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005678 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005679 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005680 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5681
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005682 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005683 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005684 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5685}
5686
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005687inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005688 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff94a5aca2007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005689 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005690 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005691
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005692 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005693
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005694 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005695 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005696 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005697}
5698
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005699inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005700 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005701 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5702 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5703 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005704
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005705 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5706 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005707
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005708 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005709 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005710
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005711 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5712 // non-overloadable operands.
5713
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005714 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5715 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005716 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5717 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5718 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005719 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005720
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005721 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5722 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5723 // The result is a bool.
5724 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005725}
5726
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005727/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5728/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5729/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5730///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005731static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005732 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5733 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5734 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5735 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005736 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005737 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5738 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5739 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5740 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005741 }
5742 }
5743 return false;
5744}
5745
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005746/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5747/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5748static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005749 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005750 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005751 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005752 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5753 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005754 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5755 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005756
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005757 unsigned Diag = 0;
5758 bool NeedType = false;
5759 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005760 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005761 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005762 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5763 NeedType = true;
5764 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005765 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005766 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5767 NeedType = true;
5768 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005769 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005770 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5771 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005772 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5773 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005774 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005775 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5776 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005777 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5778 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005779 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5780 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005781 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005782 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005783 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005784 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005785 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5786 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005787 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005788 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5789 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005790 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5791 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5792 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005793 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5794 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5795 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005796 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5797 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5798 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005799 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005800
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005801 SourceRange Assign;
5802 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5803 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005804 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005805 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005806 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005807 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005808 return true;
5809}
5810
5811
5812
5813// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005814QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5815 SourceLocation Loc,
5816 QualType CompoundType) {
5817 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5818 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005819 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005820
5821 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5822 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005823 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005824 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005825 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005826 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005827 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5828 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5829 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5830 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5831 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5832 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5833 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5834 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5835 }
5836 }
5837
5838 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005839 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5840 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5841 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005842 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005843 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005844 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005845 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005846
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005847 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5848 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5849 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005850 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005851 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5852 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5853 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5854 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5855 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005856 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005857 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005858 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5859 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5860 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005861 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5862 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005863 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5864 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5865 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005866 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005867 }
5868 } else {
5869 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005870 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005871 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005872
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005873 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005874 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005875 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005876
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005877 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5878 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005879 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005880 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5881 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005882 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005883 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005884 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005885}
5886
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005887// C99 6.5.17
5888QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00005889 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
5890
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005891 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005892 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5893 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5894 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005895
5896 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5897 // incomplete in C++).
5898
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005899 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00005900}
5901
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005902/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5903/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005904QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005905 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005906 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5907 return Context.DependentTy;
5908
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005909 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5910 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00005911
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005912 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5913 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5914 if (!isInc) {
5915 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5916 return QualType();
5917 }
5918 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5919 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5920 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005921 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005922 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5923 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005924
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005925 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005926 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005927 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5928 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5929 << Op->getSourceRange();
5930 return QualType();
5931 }
5932
5933 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005934 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005935 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005936 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5937 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5938 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5939 return QualType();
5940 }
5941
5942 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005943 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005944 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005945 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005946 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005947 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005948 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005949 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005950 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005951 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5952 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5953 return QualType();
5954 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005955 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005956 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5957 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005958 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005959 } else {
5960 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005961 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005962 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00005963 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005964 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005965 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005966 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005967 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005968 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5969 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5970 // operand.
5971 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5972 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005973}
5974
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005975/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005976/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005977/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5978/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5979/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5980/// - &(x) => x
5981/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5982/// - &s.xx => s
5983/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5984/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5985/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5986/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005987static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005988 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005989 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005990 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005991 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005992 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5993 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5994 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005995 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005996 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005997 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005998 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005999 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006000 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6001 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006002 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6003 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6004 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6005 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6006 }
6007 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006008 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006009 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6010 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006011
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006012 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006013 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6014 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6015 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6016 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6017 default:
6018 return 0;
6019 }
6020 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006021 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006022 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006023 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006024 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6025 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006026 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006027 default:
6028 return 0;
6029 }
6030}
6031
6032/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006033/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006034/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006035/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006036/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006037/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006038/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006039QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006040 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6041 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6042
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006043 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6044 return Context.DependentTy;
6045
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006046 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6047 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6048 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6049 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6050 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6051 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6052 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6053 }
6054 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6055 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6056 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006057 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006058 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006059
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006060 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6061 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6062 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6063 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6064 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6065 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6066 // branch of the if, below.
6067 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6068 << dcl;
6069 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6070
6071 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6072 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6073 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6074 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006075 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6076 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6077 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6078 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6079 if (isSFINAEContext())
6080 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian6fdb1392010-06-17 21:45:48 +00006081 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
6082 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006083 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006084 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006085 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006086 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006087 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006088 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6089 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006090 return QualType();
6091 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006092 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006093 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6094 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6095 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006096 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006097 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006098 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006099 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006100 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006101 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006102 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6103 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6104 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6105 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6106 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006107 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6108 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006109 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6110 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006111 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6112 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006113 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006114 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006115 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6116 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006117 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006118 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6119 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006120 return QualType();
6121 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006122 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006123 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006124 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006125 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006126 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6127 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006128 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006129 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006130 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6131 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006132 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006133 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6134 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6135 return QualType();
6136 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006137
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006138 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6139 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006140 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006141 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006142 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006143 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006144 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006145 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6146 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006147 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6148 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6149 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006150 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006151 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006152
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006153 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6154 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6155 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6156 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6157 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6158 }
6159
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006160 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006161 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006162}
6163
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006164QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006165 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6166 return Context.DependentTy;
6167
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006168 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6169 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006170
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006171 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6172 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6173 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6174 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006175 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006176 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006177
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006178 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanianf15d4b62009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006179 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006180
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006181 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006182 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006183 return QualType();
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006184}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006185
6186static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6187 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6188 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6189 switch (Kind) {
6190 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006191 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6192 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006193 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6194 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6195 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6196 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6197 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6198 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6199 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6200 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6201 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6202 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6203 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6204 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6205 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6206 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6207 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6208 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6209 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6210 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6211 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6212 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6213 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6214 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6215 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6216 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6217 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6218 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6219 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6220 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6221 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6222 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6223 }
6224 return Opc;
6225}
6226
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006227static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6228 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6229 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6230 switch (Kind) {
6231 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6232 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6233 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6234 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6235 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6236 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6237 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6238 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6239 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006240 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6241 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006242 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006243 }
6244 return Opc;
6245}
6246
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006247/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6248/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6249/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006250Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6251 unsigned Op,
6252 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006253 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006254 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006255 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6256 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6257 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006258
6259 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006260 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6261 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6262 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006263 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6264 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6265 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6266 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6267 break;
6268 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006269 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006270 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6271 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006272 break;
6273 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6274 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6275 break;
6276 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6277 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6278 break;
6279 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6280 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6281 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006282 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006283 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6284 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6285 break;
6286 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6287 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6288 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6289 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006290 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006291 break;
6292 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6293 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006294 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006295 break;
6296 case BinaryOperator::And:
6297 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6298 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6299 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6300 break;
6301 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6302 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6303 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6304 break;
6305 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6306 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006307 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6308 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006309 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6310 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6311 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006312 break;
6313 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006314 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6315 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6316 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6317 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006318 break;
6319 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006320 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6321 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6322 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006323 break;
6324 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006325 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6326 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6327 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006328 break;
6329 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6330 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006331 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6332 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6333 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6334 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006335 break;
6336 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6337 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6338 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006339 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6340 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6341 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6342 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006343 break;
6344 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6345 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6346 break;
6347 }
6348 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006349 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006350 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006351 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6352 else
6353 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006354 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6355 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006356}
6357
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006358/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6359/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006360static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6361 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006362 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6363 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6364 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006365 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006366 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6367
6368 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6369 return;
6370
6371 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6372 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6373 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006374 return;
6375 }
6376
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006377 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6378 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006379 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006380
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006381 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006382 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006383
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006384 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6385 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6386 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6387 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006388 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006389 return;
6390 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006391
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006392 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006393 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6394 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006395}
6396
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006397/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6398/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6399/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6400/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006401static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6402 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006403 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6404 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6405 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6406 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006407 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006408 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006409 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6410
6411 // Subs are not binary operators.
6412 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6413 return;
6414
6415 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6416 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006417 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6418 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006419 return;
6420
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006421 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006422 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006423 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006424 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6425 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006426 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006427 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006428 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6429 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6430 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6431 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006432 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006433 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006434 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006435 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6436 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006437 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006438 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006439 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6440 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6441 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6442 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006443}
6444
6445/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6446/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6447/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6448static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6449 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006450 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006451 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6452}
6453
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006454// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006455Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6456 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6457 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006458 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006459 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006460
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006461 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6462 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006463
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006464 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6465 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6466
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006467 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6468}
6469
6470Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6471 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6472 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006473 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006474 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006475 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6476 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6477 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6478 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6479 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006480 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006481 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006482 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6483 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6484 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006485
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006486 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6487 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006488 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006489 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006490
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006491 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006492 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006493}
6494
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006495Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006496 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006497 ExprArg InputArg) {
6498 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006499
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006500 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006501 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006502 QualType resultType;
6503 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006504 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6505 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6506 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006507
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006508 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6509 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006510 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6511 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006512 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006513 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006514 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6515 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6516 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006517 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006518 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006519 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006520 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006521 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006522 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006523 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006524 break;
6525 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6526 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006527 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6528 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006529 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6530 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006531 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6532 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006533 break;
6534 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6535 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6536 break;
6537 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6538 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6539 resultType->isPointerType())
6540 break;
6541
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006542 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6543 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006544 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006545 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6546 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006547 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6548 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006549 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6550 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6551 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006552 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006553 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006554 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006555 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6556 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006557 break;
6558 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006559 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006560 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006561 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006562 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6563 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006564 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006565 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6566 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006567 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006568 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6569 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006570 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006571 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006572 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006573 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006574 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006575 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006576 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006577 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006578 }
6579 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006580 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006581
6582 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006583 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006584}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006585
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006586Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6587 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6588 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006589 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006590 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6591 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006592 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6593 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6594 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6595 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006596 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006597 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006598 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6599 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6600 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006601
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006602 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6603 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006604
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006605 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6606}
6607
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006608// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6609Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6610 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6611 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6612}
6613
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006614/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006615Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6616 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6617 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006618 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006619 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006620
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006621 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6622 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006623 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006624 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006625
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006626 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006627 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6628 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006629}
6630
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006631Sema::OwningExprResult
6632Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6633 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6634 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006635 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6636 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6637
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006638 bool isFileScope
6639 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006640 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006641 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006642
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006643 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6644 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6645 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006646
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006647 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6648 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6649 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006650
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006651 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6652 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6653 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6654 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6655 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006656
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006657 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006658 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006659 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006660
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006661 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6662 // expressions are not lvalues.
6663
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006664 substmt.release();
6665 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006666}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006667
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006668Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6669 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006670 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6671 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006672 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6673 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006674 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006675 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006676
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006677 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6678 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6679 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006680 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006681 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6682 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6683
6684 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6685 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6686 if (!Dependent
6687 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6688 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6689 << TypeRange))
6690 return ExprError();
6691
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006692 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6693 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006694 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6695 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006696 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006697 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6698 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006699
6700 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6701 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6702 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6703 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6704 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6705 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6706 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6707 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6708 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6709 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6710 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6711 if(!AT)
6712 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6713 << CurrentType);
6714 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6715 } else
6716 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6717
6718 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6719 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6720 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6721 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6722 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6723 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6724 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6725 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6726
6727 // Record this array index.
6728 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6729 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6730 continue;
6731 }
6732
6733 // Offset of a field.
6734 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6735 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6736 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6737 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6738 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6739 continue;
6740 }
6741
6742 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6743 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6744 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6745 return ExprError();
6746
6747 // Look for the designated field.
6748 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6749 if (!RC)
6750 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6751 << CurrentType);
6752 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6753
6754 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6755 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6756 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6757 // (clause 9).
6758 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6759 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6760 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6761 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6762 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6763 << CurrentType))
6764 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6765 }
6766
6767 // Look for the field.
6768 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6769 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6770 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6771 if (!MemberDecl)
6772 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6773 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6774 OC.LocEnd));
6775
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006776 // C99 7.17p3:
6777 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6778 //
6779 // We diagnose this as an error.
6780 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6781 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6782 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6783 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6784 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6785 return ExprError();
6786 }
6787
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006788 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6789 // the base class indirections.
6790 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6791 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6792 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6793 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6794 Paths)) {
6795 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6796 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6797 B != BEnd; ++B)
6798 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6799 }
6800
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006801 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006802 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006803 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6804 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6805 unsigned n = Path.size();
6806 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6807 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6808 } else {
6809 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6810 }
6811 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6812 }
6813
6814 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6815 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6816 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6817}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006818
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006819Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6820 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6821 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6822 TypeTy *argty,
6823 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6824 unsigned NumComponents,
6825 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6826
6827 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6828 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6829 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6830 return ExprError();
6831
6832 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6833 if (!ArgTInfo)
6834 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6835
6836 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6837 RPLoc);
6838 }
6839
6840 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6841 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6842
6843 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6844
6845 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6846 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6847 // a struct/union/class.
6848 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6849 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6850
6851 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6852 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6853
6854 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6855 // the offsetof designators.
6856 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6857 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6858 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6859 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6860
6861 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6862 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6863 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6864 // a system header!
6865 if (NumComponents != 1)
6866 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6867 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6868
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006869 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006870 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006871
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006872 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6873 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6874 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006875
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006876 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6877 // leaks like a sieve.
6878 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6879 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6880 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6881 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6882 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6883 if (!AT) {
6884 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006885 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006886 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006887 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006888
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006889 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006890
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006891 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6892 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006893 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006894
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006895 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6896 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006897 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006898 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006899 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006900 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006901 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6902
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006903 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6904 OC.LocEnd);
6905 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006906 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006907
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006908 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006909 if (!RC) {
6910 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006911 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006912 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006913 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006914
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006915 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6916 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006917 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006918 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6919 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6920 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006921 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6922 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006923 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006924 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006925
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006926 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6927 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006928
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006929 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006930 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006931 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006932 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006933 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6934
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006935 // C99 7.17p3:
6936 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6937 //
6938 // We diagnose this as an error.
6939 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6940 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6941 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6942 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6943 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6944 return ExprError();
6945 }
6946
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006947 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6948 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006949 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006950 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006951 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006952 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006953 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6954 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006955 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6956 // doesn't matter here.
6957 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006958 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006959 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006960 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006961 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006962
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006963 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6964 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006965}
6966
6967
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006968Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6969 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6970 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006971 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6972 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6973 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006974
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006975 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006976
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006977 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6978 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6979 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6980 return ExprError();
6981 }
6982
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006983 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6984 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006985}
6986
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006987Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6988 ExprArg cond,
6989 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6990 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6991 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6992 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6993 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006994
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006995 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6996
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006997 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006998 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006999 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007000 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007001 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007002 } else {
7003 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7004 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7005 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7006 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007007 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7008 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7009 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007010
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007011 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7012 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007013 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7014 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007015 }
7016
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007017 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
7018 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007019 resType, RPLoc,
7020 resType->isDependentType(),
7021 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007022}
7023
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007024//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7025// Clang Extensions.
7026//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7027
7028/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007029void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007030 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7031 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7032 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
7033 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007034}
7035
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007036void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007037 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007038 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007039
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007040 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007041 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007042 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007043
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007044 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007045 QualType RetTy;
7046 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007047 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007048 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007049 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007050 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7051 } else {
7052 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007053 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007054 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007055
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007056 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007057
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007058 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7059 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7060 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007061 return;
7062 }
7063
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007064 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7065 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7066 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7067 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7068 return;
7069 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007070
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007071 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007072 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7073 // ^ * { ... }
7074 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007075 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7076 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007077
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007078 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007079 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007080 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7081 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7082 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7083 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007084 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7085 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7086 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7087 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7088 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007089 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007090 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007091
7092 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7093 // ^ fntype { ... }
7094 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7095 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7096 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7097 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7098 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7099 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7100 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007101 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007102 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007103 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007104
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007105 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7106 if (!Params.empty())
7107 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007108
7109 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007110 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007111
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007112 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007113 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7114 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7115 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7116 }
7117
7118 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7119 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007120 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007121 return;
7122
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007123 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7124 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7125
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007126 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007127 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7128 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7129
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007130 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007131 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7132 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7133 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7134
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007135 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007136 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007137 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007138}
7139
7140/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7141/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7142void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007143 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007144 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007145 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007146 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007147}
7148
7149/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7150/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007151Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7152 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007153 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7154 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7155 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007156
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007157 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007158
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007159 PopDeclContext();
7160
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007161 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007162 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7163 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007164
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007165 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007166 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007167
7168 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7169 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7170 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7171
7172 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7173 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7174
7175 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7176 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7177 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7178 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7179
7180 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7181 // preserve its sugar structure.
7182 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7183 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7184 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7185
7186 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7187 } else {
7188 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7189 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7190 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7191 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7192 FPT->isVariadic(),
7193 /*quals*/ 0,
7194 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7195 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7196 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7197 FPT->exception_begin(),
7198 Ext);
7199 }
7200
7201 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7202 } else {
7203 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7204 false, false, 0, 0,
7205 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7206 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007207
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007208 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007209 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7210 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007211 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007212
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007213 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007214 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007215 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007216
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007217 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007218
7219 bool Good = true;
7220 // Check goto/label use.
7221 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7222 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7223 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7224
7225 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7226 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7227 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7228 continue;
7229
7230 // Emit error.
7231 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7232 Good = false;
7233 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007234 if (!Good) {
7235 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007236 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007237 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007238
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007239 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007240 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7241 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7242 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007243
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007244 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7245 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007246 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007247 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007248}
7249
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007250Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7251 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7252 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007253 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007254 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7255 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007256
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007257 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007258
7259 // Get the va_list type
7260 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007261 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7262 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7263 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7264 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007265 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007266 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7267 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7268 } else {
7269 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7270 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007271 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007272 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007273 return ExprError();
7274 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007275
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007276 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7277 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007278 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7279 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007280 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007281 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007282
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007283 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007284 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007285
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007286 expr.release();
7287 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7288 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007289}
7290
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007291Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007292 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7293 // pointers on the target.
7294 QualType Ty;
7295 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7296 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7297 else
7298 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7299
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007300 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007301}
7302
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007303static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007304 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007305 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7306 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007307
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007308 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7309 if (!PT)
7310 return;
7311
7312 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7313 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7314 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7315 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7316 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7317 return;
7318 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007319
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007320 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7321 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7322 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7323 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007324
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007325 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007326}
7327
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007328bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7329 SourceLocation Loc,
7330 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007331 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7332 bool *Complained) {
7333 if (Complained)
7334 *Complained = false;
7335
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007336 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7337 bool isInvalid = false;
7338 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007339 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007340
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007341 switch (ConvTy) {
7342 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7343 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007344 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007345 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7346 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007347 case IntToPointer:
7348 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7349 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007350 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007351 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007352 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7353 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007354 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7355 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7356 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007357 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7358 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7359 break;
7360 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007361 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7362 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7363 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7364 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7365 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7366 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7367 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7368 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7369 // C++ semantics.
7370 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7371 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7372 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007373 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7374 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007375 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007376 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007377 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007378 case IntToBlockPointer:
7379 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7380 break;
7381 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007382 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007383 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007384 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007385 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007386 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7387 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7388 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007389 case IncompatibleVectors:
7390 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7391 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007392 case Incompatible:
7393 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7394 isInvalid = true;
7395 break;
7396 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007397
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007398 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7399 switch (Action) {
7400 case AA_Assigning:
7401 case AA_Initializing:
7402 // The destination type comes first.
7403 FirstType = DstType;
7404 SecondType = SrcType;
7405 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007406
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007407 case AA_Returning:
7408 case AA_Passing:
7409 case AA_Converting:
7410 case AA_Sending:
7411 case AA_Casting:
7412 // The source type comes first.
7413 FirstType = SrcType;
7414 SecondType = DstType;
7415 break;
7416 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007417
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007418 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007419 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007420 if (Complained)
7421 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007422 return isInvalid;
7423}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007424
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007425bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007426 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7427 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7428 if (Result)
7429 *Result = ICEResult;
7430 return false;
7431 }
7432
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007433 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7434
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007435 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007436 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7437 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7438
7439 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7440 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7441 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7442 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7443 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7444 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7445 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007446
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007447 return true;
7448 }
7449
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007450 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7451 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007452
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007453 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7454 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7455 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007456
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007457 if (Result)
7458 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7459 return false;
7460}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007461
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007462void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007463Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007464 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7465 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007466}
7467
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007468void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007469Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7470 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7471 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7472 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007473
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007474 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7475 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7476 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7477 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7478 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007479 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007480 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7481 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7482 I != IEnd; ++I)
7483 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7484 }
7485
7486 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7487 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7488 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7489 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7490 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7491 I != IEnd; ++I)
7492 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7493 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007494 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007495
7496 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7497 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7498 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7499 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007500 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007501 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7502 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7503 ExprTemporaries.end());
7504
7505 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7506 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007507}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007508
7509/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7510///
7511/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7512/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7513/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7514/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7515///
7516/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7517///
7518/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7519void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7520 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007521
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007522 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007523 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007524
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007525 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7526 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7527 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7528 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007529 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007530 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007531 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007532 return;
7533 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007534
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007535 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7536 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007537
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007538 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7539 // an instantiation.
7540 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7541 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007542
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007543 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007544 case Unevaluated:
7545 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7546 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007547
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007548 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7549 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7550 // "used"; handle this below.
7551 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007552
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007553 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7554 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7555 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7556 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007557 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007558 return;
7559 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007560
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007561 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007562 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007563 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007564 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007565 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007566 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007567 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007568 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007569 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007570 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7571 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007572
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007573 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007574 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007575 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007576 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007577 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7578 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007579 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7580 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7581 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007582 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007583 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007584 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7585 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007586 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007587 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007588 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007589 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007590 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007591 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7592 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7593 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7594 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7595 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007596 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007597 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007598 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007599 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007600 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7601 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7602 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007603 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007604 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007605 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7606 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007607
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007608 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7609 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7610 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7611 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7612 Loc));
7613 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007614 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007615 Loc));
7616 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007617 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007618
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007619 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007620 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007621
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007622 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007623 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007624
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007625 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007626 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007627 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007628 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7629 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7630 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7631 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7632 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7633 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7634 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7635 }
7636 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007637
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007638 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007639
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007640 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007641 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007642 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007643}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007644
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007645namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007646 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007647 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007648 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007649 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7650 Sema &S;
7651 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007652
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007653 public:
7654 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007655
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007656 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007657
7658 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7659 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007660 };
7661}
7662
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007663bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7664 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007665 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7666 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7667 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007668
7669 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007670}
7671
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007672bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007673 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7674 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7675 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007676 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7677 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007678 }
7679
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007680 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007681}
7682
7683void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7684 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007685 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007686}
7687
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007688/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7689/// of the program being compiled.
7690///
7691/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007692/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007693/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7694/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7695/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7696/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007697/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007698/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007699///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007700/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7701/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7702/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7703/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007704bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007705 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7706 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7707 case Unevaluated:
7708 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7709 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007710
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007711 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7712 Diag(Loc, PD);
7713 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007714
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007715 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7716 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7717 break;
7718 }
7719
7720 return false;
7721}
7722
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007723bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7724 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7725 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7726 return false;
7727
7728 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7729 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7730 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7731 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007732
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007733 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007734 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007735 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7736 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007737 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007738 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7739 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7740 return true;
7741
7742 return false;
7743}
7744
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007745// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7746// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7747void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7748 SourceLocation Loc;
7749
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007750 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7751
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007752 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7753 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7754 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7755 return;
7756
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007757 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7758 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7759 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7760 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7761
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007762 // self = [<foo> init...]
7763 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7764 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7765 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7766
7767 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7768 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7769 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7770 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7771 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007772
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007773 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7774 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7775 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7776 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7777 return;
7778
7779 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7780 } else {
7781 // Not an assignment.
7782 return;
7783 }
7784
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007785 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007786 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007787
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007788 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007789 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007790 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007791 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7792 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7793 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007794}
7795
7796bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7797 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7798
7799 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007800 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007801
7802 QualType T = E->getType();
7803
7804 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7805 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7806 return true;
7807 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7808 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7809 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7810 return true;
7811 }
7812 }
7813
7814 return false;
7815}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007816
7817Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7818 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007819 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7820 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007821 return ExprError();
7822
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007823 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7824 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7825 return ExprError();
7826 }
7827
7828 return Owned(Sub);
7829}